blob: 320b24227ad9618ca0df6d09a191a7c55fa44c43 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner07d754a2008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregorb53edfb2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlsson6904f642009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000381
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCallc33dec32010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattnerf83b5af2009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregored6c7442009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000499/// getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl - Retrieve the (unnamed) field or
500/// variable corresponding to the anonymous union or struct whose type
501/// is Record.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000502static Decl *getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(ASTContext &Context,
503 RecordDecl *Record) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000504 assert(Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000505 "Record must be an anonymous struct or union!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000506
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000507 // FIXME: Once Decls are directly linked together, this will be an O(1)
508 // operation rather than a slow walk through DeclContext's vector (which
509 // itself will be eliminated). DeclGroups might make this even better.
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000510 DeclContext *Ctx = Record->getDeclContext();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000511 for (DeclContext::decl_iterator D = Ctx->decls_begin(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +0000512 DEnd = Ctx->decls_end();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000513 D != DEnd; ++D) {
514 if (*D == Record) {
515 // The object for the anonymous struct/union directly
516 // follows its type in the list of declarations.
517 ++D;
518 assert(D != DEnd && "Missing object for anonymous record");
Douglas Gregor6e6ad602009-01-20 01:17:11 +0000519 assert(!cast<NamedDecl>(*D)->getDeclName() && "Decl should be unnamed");
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000520 return *D;
521 }
522 }
523
524 assert(false && "Missing object for anonymous record");
525 return 0;
526}
527
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000528/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
529/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
530/// actual member.
531///
532/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
533/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
534/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
535/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
536/// we found.
537///
538/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
539/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
540/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
541VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
542 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000543 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
544 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
545 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
546
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000547 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
549 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
550 do {
551 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +0000552 Decl *AnonObject = getObjectForAnonymousRecordDecl(Context, Record);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000553 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000554 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000555 else {
556 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
557 break;
558 }
559 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000560 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000562
563 return BaseObject;
564}
565
566Sema::OwningExprResult
567Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
568 FieldDecl *Field,
569 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
570 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
571 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000572 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000573 AnonFields);
574
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
576 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
577 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
578 // found via name lookup.
579 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000580 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000581 if (BaseObject) {
582 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
583 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000584 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000585 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000586 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000587 SourceLocation());
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000588 BaseQuals
589 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
591 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
592 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
593 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
594 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000595 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000596 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
597 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
598 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000599 BaseQuals
600 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000601 } else {
602 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
603 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
604 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000605 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
606 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000607 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000608 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 = Context.getTagDeclType(
610 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
611 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000612 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000613 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
614 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
615 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000616 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000617 MD->getThisType(Context),
618 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000619 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
620 }
621 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000622 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
623 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000624 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000625 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000626 }
627
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000628 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000629 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
630 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000631 }
632
633 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
634 // anonymous struct/union.
635 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
638 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
639 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
640 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000641 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
642 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
643
644 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
645 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
646 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
647 ResultQuals.removeConst();
648
649 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
650 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
651
652 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
653 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
654
655 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
656 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
657 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
658
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000659 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000660 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000661 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000662 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
663 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000664 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000665 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000666 }
667
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000668 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000669}
670
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000671/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
672/// possibly a list of template arguments.
673///
674/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
675/// DecomposeTemplateName.
676///
677/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
678/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
679/// some way.
680static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
681 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
682 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
683 DeclarationName &Name,
684 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
685 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
686 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
687 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
688 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
689
690 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
691 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
692 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
693 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
694 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
695
696 TemplateName TName =
697 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
698
699 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
700 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
701 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
702 } else {
703 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
704 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
705 TemplateArgs = 0;
706 }
707}
708
709/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
710///
711/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
712/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
713/// found template arguments.
714static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
715 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
716 TemplateName TName =
717 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
718
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000719 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
720 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000721 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
722 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
723 I != E; ++I)
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000724 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCalla9ee3252009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000725
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000726 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000727}
728
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000729/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
730/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
731/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000732static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000733 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
734 return false;
735
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000736 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
737 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
738 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
739 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
740 if (!BaseRT) return false;
741
742 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000743 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000744 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
745 return false;
746 }
747
748 return true;
749}
750
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000751/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
752/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
753static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000754 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000755
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000756 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
757 if (!DC) return true;
758
759 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
760 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
761
762 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
763 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
764
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765 return false;
766}
John McCallf786fb12009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000767
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000768/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
769/// the prospective base classes.
770static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
771 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
772 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000773 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000774 return false;
775
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000776 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000777 if (!RD) return false;
778 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
779
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000780 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
781 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
782 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
783 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
784 if (!BaseRT) return false;
785
786 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
788 return false;
789 }
790
791 return true;
792}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000793
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000794enum IMAKind {
795 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
796 IMA_Static,
797
798 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
799 IMA_Mixed,
800
801 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
802 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
803 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
804
805 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
806 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
807 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
808
809 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
810 IMA_Instance,
811
812 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
813 IMA_Unresolved,
814
815 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
816 /// context is not an instance method.
817 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
818
819 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
820 /// non-class context.
821 IMA_AnonymousMember,
822
823 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
824 /// context is not an instance method.
825 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
826
827 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
828 /// class.
829 IMA_Error_Unrelated
830};
831
832/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
833/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
834/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
835/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
836/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
837/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
838static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
839 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000840 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000841
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000842 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000843 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000844 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
845 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000846
847 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
848 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
849
850 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
851 bool hasNonInstance = false;
852 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
853 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000854 NamedDecl *D = *I;
855 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000856 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
857
858 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
859 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
860 // that's a special case.
861 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
862 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
863 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
864 }
865 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
866 }
867 else
868 hasNonInstance = true;
869 }
870
871 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
872 // member reference.
873 if (Classes.empty())
874 return IMA_Static;
875
876 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
877 // an implicit member reference.
878 if (isStaticContext)
879 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
880
881 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
882 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
883 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
884 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000885 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000886 Classes))
887 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
888
889 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
890}
891
892/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
893static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
894 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
895 const LookupResult &R) {
896 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
897 SourceRange Range(Loc);
898 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
899
900 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
901 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
902 if (MD->isStatic()) {
903 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
904 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
905 << Range << R.getLookupName();
906 return;
907 }
908 }
909
910 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
911 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
912 return;
913 }
914
915 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000916}
917
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000918/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
919///
920/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000921bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000922 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000923 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
924
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000926 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
928 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000929 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000930 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000931 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
932 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000933
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000934 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
935 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
936 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
937 // dependent name.
938 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
939 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000940 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
941 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
942
943 if (!R.empty()) {
944 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
945 R.suppressDiagnostics();
946
947 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
948 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
949 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
950 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
951
952 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
953 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
954 // Actually quite difficult!
955 if (isInstance)
956 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000957 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000958 else
959 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
960
961 // Do we really want to note all of these?
962 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
963 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
964
965 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
966 return false;
967 }
968 }
969 }
970
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000971 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000972 DeclarationName Corrected;
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000973 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000974 if (!R.empty()) {
975 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
976 if (SS.isEmpty())
977 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
978 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
979 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
980 else
981 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
982 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
983 << SS.getRange()
984 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
985 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
986 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
987 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
988 << ND->getDeclName();
989
990 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
991 return false;
992 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000993
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000994 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
995 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
996 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
997 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
998 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
999 // to recover well anyway.
1000 if (SS.isEmpty())
1001 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1002 else
1003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1004 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1005 << SS.getRange();
1006
1007 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1008 return true;
1009 }
1010 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001011 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001012 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001013 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001014 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001015 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001016 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001017 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1018 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001019 return true;
1020 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001021 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001022 }
1023
1024 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1025 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1026 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1027 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1028 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1029 << SS.getRange();
1030 return true;
1031 }
1032
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001033 // Give up, we can't recover.
1034 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1035 return true;
1036}
1037
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001039 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001040 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1041 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1042 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1043 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1044 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1045
1046 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001047 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001048
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001049 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050
1051 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1052 DeclarationName Name;
1053 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1054 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001055 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1056 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001057
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001058 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001059
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001060 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1061 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001062 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1063 // (note: handled after lookup)
1064 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1065 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1066 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001067 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1068 // names a dependent type.
1069 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1070 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001071 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1072 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1073 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001074 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001075 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 TemplateArgs);
1077 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001078
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001079 // Perform the required lookup.
1080 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1081 if (TemplateArgs) {
Daniel Dunbarfd5ed842010-05-19 21:07:14 +00001082 // Just re-use the lookup done by isTemplateName.
1083 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
1084
1085 // Re-derive the naming class.
1086 if (SS.isSet()) {
1087 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
1088 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
1089 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
1090 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
1091 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
1092 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001094 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1095 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001096
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001097 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1098 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001099 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1100 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001101 if (E.isInvalid())
1102 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001103
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001104 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1105 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001106 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001107 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001108
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001109 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1110 return ExprError();
1111
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001112 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1113 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001114 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001115
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001116 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001117 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001118 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1119 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1120 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1121 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1122 }
1123
1124 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1125 // call, diagnose the problem.
1126 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001127 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001128 return ExprError();
1129
1130 assert(!R.empty() &&
1131 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001132
1133 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1134 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001135 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001136 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1137 R.clear();
1138 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1139 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1140 return move(E);
1141 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001142 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001143 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001144
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1146 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1147
1148 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001149 // Warn about constructs like:
1150 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1151 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1153 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001154 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001155 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001156 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001157 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001158 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattnerdf742642010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001159 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1160 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001161 break;
1162 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001163
Douglas Gregor13a2c032009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001164 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1165 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001166 }
1167 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001169 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1170 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1171 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1172 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1173 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1174 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001175 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001176 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001177
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001178 QualType T = Func->getType();
1179 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001180 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001181 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1182 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001183 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001184 }
1185 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001186
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001187 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1188 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1189 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1190 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1191 // class member access expression.
1192 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1193 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001194 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001195 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001196 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1197 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001198 }
1199
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001200 if (TemplateArgs)
1201 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001202
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001203 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1204}
1205
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001206/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1207Sema::OwningExprResult
1208Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1209 LookupResult &R,
1210 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1211 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1212 case IMA_Instance:
1213 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1214
1215 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1216 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1217 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1218 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1219
1220 case IMA_Mixed:
1221 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1222 case IMA_Unresolved:
1223 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1224
1225 case IMA_Static:
1226 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1227 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1228 if (TemplateArgs)
1229 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1230 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1231
1232 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1233 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1234 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1235 return ExprError();
1236 }
1237
1238 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1239 return ExprError();
1240}
1241
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001242/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1243/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1244/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1245/// this path.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001246Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001247Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001248 DeclarationName Name,
1249 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1250 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001251 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001252 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1253
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001254 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001255 return ExprError();
1256
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001257 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1258 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1259
1260 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1261 return ExprError();
1262
1263 if (R.empty()) {
1264 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1265 return ExprError();
1266 }
1267
1268 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1269}
1270
1271/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1272/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1273/// additional lookup.
1274///
1275/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1276/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1277///
1278/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1279Sema::OwningExprResult
1280Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001281 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001282 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001283 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001284
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001285 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1286 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1287 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1288 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1289 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1290
1291 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1292 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1293 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001294 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001295
1296 bool LookForIvars;
1297 if (Lookup.empty())
1298 LookForIvars = true;
1299 else if (IsClassMethod)
1300 LookForIvars = false;
1301 else
1302 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1303 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001304 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001305 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001306 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001307 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1308 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1309 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1310 if (IsClassMethod)
1311 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1312 << IV->getDeclName());
1313
1314 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1315 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1316 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1317 return ExprError();
1318
1319 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1320 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1321 return ExprError();
1322
1323 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1324 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1325 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1326 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1327
1328 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1329 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1330 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1331 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001332 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001333 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1334 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1335 SelfName, false, false);
1336 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1337 return Owned(new (Context)
1338 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1339 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1340 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001341 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001342 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001343 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001344 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1345 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1346 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1347 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1348 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1349 }
1350 }
1351
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001352 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1353 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1354 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1355 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1356 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1357 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1358 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1359 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1360 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1361 }
1362 }
1363 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001364 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1365 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001366}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001367
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001368/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1369///
1370/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1371///
1372/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1373/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1374/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1375/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1376///
1377/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1378/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1379/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1380/// the class declaring the member.
1381///
1382/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1383/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1384/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001385bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001386Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1387 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001388 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001389 NamedDecl *Member) {
1390 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1391 if (!RD)
1392 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001393
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001394 QualType DestRecordType;
1395 QualType DestType;
1396 QualType FromRecordType;
1397 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1398 bool PointerConversions = false;
1399 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1400 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001401
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001402 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1403 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1404 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1405 PointerConversions = true;
1406 } else {
1407 DestType = DestRecordType;
1408 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001409 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1411 if (Method->isStatic())
1412 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001413
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001414 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1415 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001416
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001417 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1418 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1419 PointerConversions = true;
1420 } else {
1421 FromRecordType = FromType;
1422 DestType = DestRecordType;
1423 }
1424 } else {
1425 // No conversion necessary.
1426 return false;
1427 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001428
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001429 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1430 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001431
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001432 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1433 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1434 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001435
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001436 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1437 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1438
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001439 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001440 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001441 // class name.
1442 //
1443 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1444 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1445 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1446 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1447 //
1448 // class Base { public: int x; };
1449 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1450 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1451 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1452 //
1453 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1454 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1455 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1456 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001457 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001458 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1459 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1460 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1461
1462 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1463
1464 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1465 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1466 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1467 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001468 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001469 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001470 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001471 return true;
1472
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001473 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001474 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001475 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001476 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001477
1478 FromType = QType;
1479 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1480
1481 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1482 // we're done.
1483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1484 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 }
1486 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001487
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001488 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001490 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1491 // down to the using declaration's type.
1492 //
1493 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1494 // class ever has member declarations.
1495 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1496 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1497 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1498 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1499
1500 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1501 // conversion is non-trivial.
1502 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1503 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001504 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001505 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001506 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001507 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001508
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001509 QualType UType = URecordType;
1510 if (PointerConversions)
1511 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001512 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001513 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001514 FromType = UType;
1515 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1516 }
1517
1518 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1519 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1520 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001521 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001522
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001523 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1524 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1525 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001526 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001527 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001528
John McCalld9c7c6562010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001529 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001530 /*isLvalue=*/!PointerConversions, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001531 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001532}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001533
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001534/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001535static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001536 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001537 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1538 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001539 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1540 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1541 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001542 if (SS.isSet()) {
1543 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1544 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001545 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001546
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001547 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001549}
1550
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001551/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1552/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1553/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1554/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001555Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001556Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1557 LookupResult &R,
1558 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1559 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001560 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1561
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001562 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001563
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001564 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1565 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001566 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001567 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001568 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001569 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001570 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001571
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001572 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1573 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001574 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1575 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001576 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1577 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001578 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1579 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1580 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1581 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001582 }
1583
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001584 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1585 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1586 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001587 SS,
1588 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1589 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001590}
1591
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001592bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001593 const LookupResult &R,
1594 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001595 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1596 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1597 return false;
1598
1599 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001600 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001601 return false;
1602
1603 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001604 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001605 return false;
1606
1607 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1608 // normal lookup:
1609 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1610 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1611
1612 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1613 // -- a declaration of a class member
1614 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1615 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001616 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001617 return false;
1618
1619 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1620 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1621 // using-declaration
1622 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1623 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1624 // turn off ADL anyway).
1625 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1626 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1627 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1628 return false;
1629
1630 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1631 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1632 // template
1633 // And also for builtin functions.
1634 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1635 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1636
1637 // But also builtin functions.
1638 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1639 return false;
1640 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1641 return false;
1642 }
1643
1644 return true;
1645}
1646
1647
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001648/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1649/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1650/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1651/// will in fact be used.
1652static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1653 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1654 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1655 return true;
1656 }
1657
1658 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1659 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1660 return true;
1661 }
1662
1663 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1664 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1665 return true;
1666 }
1667
1668 return false;
1669}
1670
1671Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001672Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001673 LookupResult &R,
1674 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001675 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1676 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001677 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001678 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001679
1680 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1681 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1682 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1684 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001685 return ExprError();
1686
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001687 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1688 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1689 // we've picked a target.
1690 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1691
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001692 bool Dependent
1693 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001694 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001695 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001696 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1697 SS.getRange(),
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001698 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
1699 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001700 ULE->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001701
1702 return Owned(ULE);
1703}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001704
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001705
1706/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1707Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001708Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001709 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1710 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001711 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1712 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001713
1714 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1715 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001716
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001717 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1718 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1719 // a template argument list.
1720 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1721 << Template << SS.getRange();
1722 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1723 return ExprError();
1724 }
1725
1726 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1727 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1728 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001729 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001730 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001731 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001732 return ExprError();
1733 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001734
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001735 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1736 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1737 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1738 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001739 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001740 return ExprError();
1741
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001742 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1743 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001744 return ExprError();
1745
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001746 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1747 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1748 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1749 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001750 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001751 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1752 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1753 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001754 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001755 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001756 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1757 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1758 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1759 return ExprError();
1760 }
1761
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001762 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001763 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1764 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1765 return ExprError();
1766 }
1767
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001768 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001769 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001770 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001771 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001772 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001773 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1774 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001775 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001776
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001777 ExprTy.addConst();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001778 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001779 constAdded));
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001780 }
1781 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1782 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001783
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001784 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001785}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001786
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001787Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1788 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001789 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001790
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001791 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001792 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001793 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1794 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1795 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001796 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001797
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001798 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1799 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001800
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001801 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1802 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001803 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001804 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001805 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001806
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001807 QualType ResTy;
1808 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1809 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1810 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001811 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001812
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001813 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001814 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001815 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1816 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001817 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001818}
1819
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001820Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001821 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001822 bool Invalid = false;
1823 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1824 if (Invalid)
1825 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001826
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001827 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1828 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001829 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001830 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001831
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001832 QualType Ty;
1833 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1834 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1835 else if (Literal.isWide())
1836 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001837 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1838 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001839 else
1840 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001841
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001842 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1843 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001844 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001845}
1846
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001847Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1848 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001849 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1850 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001851 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001852 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001853 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001854 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001855 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001856
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001857 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001858 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1859 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001860 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001861
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001862 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001863 bool Invalid = false;
1864 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1865 if (Invalid)
1866 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001867
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001868 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001869 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001870 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001871 return ExprError();
1872
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001873 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001874
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001875 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001876 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001877 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001878 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001879 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001880 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001881 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001882 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001883
1884 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1885
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001886 using llvm::APFloat;
1887 APFloat Val(Format);
1888
1889 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001890
1891 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1892 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1893 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1894 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001895 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001896 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001897 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001898 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001899 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1900 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001901 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001902 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1903 }
1904
1905 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1906 << Ty
1907 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1908 }
1909
1910 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattnere4edb8e2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001911 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001912
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001913 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001914 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001915 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001916 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001917
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001918 // long long is a C99 feature.
1919 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001920 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001921 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1922
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001923 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001924 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001925
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001926 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1927 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1928 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001929 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1930 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001931 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001932 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001933 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1934 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001936 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1937 // be an unsigned int.
1938 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1939
1940 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001941 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001942 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1943 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001944 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001945
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001946 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1947 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1948 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1949 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001950 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001951 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001952 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001953 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001954 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001955 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001956
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001957 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001958 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001959 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001960
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001961 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1962 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1963 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1964 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001965 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001966 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001967 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001968 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001969 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001970 }
1971
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001972 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001973 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001974 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001976 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1977 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1978 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1979 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001980 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001981 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001982 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001983 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001984 }
1985 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001986
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001987 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1988 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001989 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001990 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001991 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001992 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001993 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001994
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001995 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1996 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001997 }
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001998 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00001999 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002000
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002001 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2002 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002003 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002004 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002005
2006 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002007}
2008
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002009Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2010 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002011 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002012 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002013 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002014}
2015
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002016/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002017/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002018bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002019 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2020 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2021 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002022 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2023 return false;
2024
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002025 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2026 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2027 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2028 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2029 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2030 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2031
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002032 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002033 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002034 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002035 if (isSizeof)
2036 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2037 return false;
2038 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002039
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002040 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002041 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002042 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2043 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002044 return false;
2045 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002046
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002047 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002048 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2049 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002050 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002051
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002052 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002053 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002054 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002055 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2056 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002057 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002058
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002059 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002060}
2061
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002062bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2063 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2064 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002065
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002066 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002067 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2068 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002069
2070 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2071 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2072 return false;
2073
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002074 if (E->getBitField()) {
2075 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2076 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002077 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002078
2079 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2080 // bit-field.
2081 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002082 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002083 return false;
2084
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002085 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2086}
2087
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002088/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002089Action::OwningExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002090Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002091 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002092 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002093 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002094 return ExprError();
2095
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002096 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002097
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002098 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2099 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2100 return ExprError();
2101
2102 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002103 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002104 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2105 R.getEnd()));
2106}
2107
2108/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2109/// operand.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002110Action::OwningExprResult
2111Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002112 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2113 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2114 bool isInvalid = false;
2115 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2116 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2117 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2118 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002119 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002120 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2121 isInvalid = true;
2122 } else {
2123 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2124 }
2125
2126 if (isInvalid)
2127 return ExprError();
2128
2129 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2130 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2131 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2132 R.getEnd()));
2133}
2134
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002135/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2136/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2137/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002138Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002139Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2140 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002141 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002142 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002143
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002144 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002145 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2146 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2147 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002148 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002149
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002150 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2151 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2152 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2153
2154 if (Result.isInvalid())
2155 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2156
2157 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002158}
2159
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002160QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002161 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2162 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002163
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002164 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002165 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002166 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002167
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002168 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2169 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2170 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002171
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002172 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002173 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2174 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002175 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002176}
2177
2178
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002179
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002180Action::OwningExprResult
2181Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2182 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002183 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2184 switch (Kind) {
2185 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2186 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2187 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2188 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002189
Eli Friedmancfdd40c2009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002190 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002191}
2192
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002193Action::OwningExprResult
2194Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2195 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002196 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2197 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2198
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002199 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2200 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002201
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002202 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002203 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2204 Base.release();
2205 Idx.release();
2206 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2207 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2208 }
2209
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002210 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002211 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002212 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2213 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2214 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002215 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002216 }
2217
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002218 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2219}
2220
2221
2222Action::OwningExprResult
2223Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2224 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2225 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2226 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2227
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002228 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002229 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2230 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2231 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002232
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002233 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002234
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002235 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002236 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002237 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002238 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002239 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2240 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002241 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2242 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2243 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2244 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002245 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2247 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002248 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002249 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002250 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002251 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2252 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002253 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002254 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002255 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002256 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2257 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2258 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002259 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002260 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002261 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2262 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2263 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2264 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002265 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002266 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002267 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002268
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002269 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2270 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002271 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2272 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002273 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002274 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2275 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2276 // force the promotion here.
2277 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2278 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002279 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2280 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002281 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2282
2283 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2284 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002285 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002286 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2287 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2288 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2289 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002290 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2291 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002292 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2293
2294 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2295 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002296 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002297 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002298 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2299 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002300 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002301 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002302 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2303 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002304 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2305 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002306
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002307 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002308 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2309 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002310 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2311
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002312 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002313 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2314 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002315 // incomplete types are not object types.
2316 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2317 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2318 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2319 return ExprError();
2320 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002321
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002322 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002324 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2325 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002326 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002327
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002328 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002329 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002330 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2331 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2332 return ExprError();
2333 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002334
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002335 Base.release();
2336 Idx.release();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002337 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002338 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002339}
2340
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002341QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002342CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002343 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002344 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002345 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2346 // see FIXME there.
2347 //
2348 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2349 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002350 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002351
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002352 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002353 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002354
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002355 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002356 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2357 // to be selected.
2358 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002359
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002360 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2361 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002362 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002363
2364 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2365 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002366 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002367 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2368 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002369 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002370 do
2371 compStr++;
2372 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002373 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002374 do
2375 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002376 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002377 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002378
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002379 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002380 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2381 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002382 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2383 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002384 return QualType();
2385 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002386
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002387 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2388 // operates on.
2389 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002390 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002391
2392 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002393 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002394
2395 while (*compStr) {
2396 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2397 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2398 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2399 return QualType();
2400 }
2401 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002403
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002404 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002405 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002406 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002407 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002408 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002409 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002410 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002411 if (HexSwizzle)
2412 CompSize--;
2413
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002414 if (CompSize == 1)
2415 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002416
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002417 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002418 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002419 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2420 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2421 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2422 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002423 }
2424 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002425}
2426
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002427static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002428 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002429 const Selector &Sel,
2430 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002432 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002433 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002434 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002435 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002436
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002437 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2438 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002439 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002440 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002441 return D;
2442 }
2443 return 0;
2444}
2445
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002446static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002447 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002448 const Selector &Sel,
2449 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002450 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2451 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002452 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002453 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002454 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002455 GDecl = PD;
2456 break;
2457 }
2458 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002459 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002460 GDecl = OMD;
2461 break;
2462 }
2463 }
2464 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002465 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002466 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2467 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002468 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002469 if (GDecl)
2470 return GDecl;
2471 }
2472 }
2473 return GDecl;
2474}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002475
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002476Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002477Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2478 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002479 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2480 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2481 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2482 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2483 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2484
2485 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2486 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2487 //
2488 // T* t;
2489 // t.f;
2490 //
2491 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2492 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2493 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2494 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002495 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002496 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2497 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002498 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002499 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002500 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002501 return ExprError();
2502 }
2503 }
2504
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002505 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002506 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002507
2508 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2509 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002510 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002511 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2512 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2513 SS.getRange(),
2514 FirstQualifierInScope,
2515 Name, NameLoc,
2516 TemplateArgs));
2517}
2518
2519/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2520/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2521/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2522static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2523 Expr *BaseExpr,
2524 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002525 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002526 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002527 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2528 // diagnostics.
2529 if (!BaseExpr)
2530 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002531
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002532 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2533 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002534}
2535
2536// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2537// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2538// type. The restriction here is:
2539//
2540// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2541// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2542// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2543//
2544// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2545// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2546// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2547// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2548bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2549 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002550 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002551 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002552 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2553 if (!BaseRT) {
2554 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2555 // dependent.
2556 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2557 return false;
2558 }
2559 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002560
2561 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002562 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2563 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002564 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002566
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002567 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2568 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2569 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2570 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2571
2572 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2573 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2574
2575 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2576 return false;
2577 }
2578
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002579 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002580 return true;
2581}
2582
2583static bool
2584LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2585 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002586 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002587 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2588 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002589 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002590 << BaseRange))
2591 return true;
2592
2593 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2594 if (SS.isSet()) {
2595 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2596 // nested-name-specifier.
2597 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2598
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002599 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002600 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2601 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2602 return true;
2603 }
2604
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002605 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002606
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002607 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2608 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2609 << DC << SS.getRange();
2610 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002611 }
2612 }
2613
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002614 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2615 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002617 if (!R.empty())
2618 return false;
2619
2620 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2621 // for typos.
2622 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002623 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002624 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002625 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2626 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2627 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002628 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2629 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002630 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2631 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2632 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002633 return false;
2634 } else {
2635 R.clear();
2636 }
2637
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638 return false;
2639}
2640
2641Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002642Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002643 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002644 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002645 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2646 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2647 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2648 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2649
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002650 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2651 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002652 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002653 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2654 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2655 Name, NameLoc,
2656 TemplateArgs);
2657
2658 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002659
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002660 // Implicit member accesses.
2661 if (!Base) {
2662 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2663 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2664 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2665 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2666 OpLoc, SS))
2667 return ExprError();
2668
2669 // Explicit member accesses.
2670 } else {
2671 OwningExprResult Result =
2672 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002673 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002674
2675 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2676 Owned(Base);
2677 return ExprError();
2678 }
2679
2680 if (Result.get())
2681 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002682
2683 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2684 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002685 }
2686
Sebastian Redl0b4e3122010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002687 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002688 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2689 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002690}
2691
2692Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002693Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2694 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2695 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002696 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002697 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002698 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2699 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002701 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002702 if (IsArrow) {
2703 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2704 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2705 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002706 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002707
2708 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2709 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2710 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2711 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2712
2713 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002714 return ExprError();
2715
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002716 if (R.empty()) {
2717 // Rederive where we looked up.
2718 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2719 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2720 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002721
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002722 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002723 << MemberName << DC
2724 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002725 return ExprError();
2726 }
2727
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002728 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2729 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2730 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2731 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2732 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2733 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2734 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2735 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2736 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2737 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002738 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002739 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002740 return ExprError();
2741
2742 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2743 // result.
2744 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002746 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002747 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002748 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002749
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002750 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2751 // pick a member.
2752 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2753
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002754 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2755 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2756 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002757 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2758 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002759 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2760 MemberName, MemberLoc,
2761 TemplateArgs);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002762 MemExpr->addDecls(R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763
2764 return Owned(MemExpr);
2765 }
2766
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002767 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002768 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2770
2771 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2772
2773 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2774 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2775 // error cases.
2776 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2777 return ExprError();
2778
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002779 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2780 if (!BaseExpr) {
2781 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002782 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002783 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2784
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002785 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2786 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2787 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2788 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002789 }
2790
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002791 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2792 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2793 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2794 // explicitly qualified.
2795 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2796 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2797 }
2798
2799 // Check the use of this member.
2800 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2801 Owned(BaseExpr);
2802 return ExprError();
2803 }
2804
2805 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2806 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2807 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002808 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2809 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002810 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2811 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2812
2813 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2814 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2815 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2816 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2817 else {
2818 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2819 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2820 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2821
2822 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2823 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2824
2825 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2826 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2827 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2828 }
2829
2830 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002831 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 return ExprError();
2833 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002834 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835 }
2836
2837 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2838 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2839 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002840 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002841 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2842 }
2843
2844 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2845 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2846 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002847 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 MemberFn->getType()));
2849 }
2850
2851 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2852 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2853 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002854 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002855 }
2856
2857 Owned(BaseExpr);
2858
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002859 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002860 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002861 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2862 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2863 else
2864 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2865 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002866
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002867 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2868 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002869 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002870 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002871}
2872
2873/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2874/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2875/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2876/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2877/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2878/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2879/// an ordinary member expression.
2880///
2881/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2882/// fixed for ObjC++.
2883Sema::OwningExprResult
2884Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002885 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002886 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002887 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002888 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002889
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002890 // Perform default conversions.
2891 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002892
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002893 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002894 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2895
2896 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2897 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002898
2899 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002900 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002901 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2902 // call, and continue on.
2903 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2904 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2905 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2906 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2907 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002908 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2909 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002910 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2911 ->isRecordType()))) {
2912 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2913 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2914 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002915 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002916
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002917 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002918 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002919 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2920 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002921 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002922
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002923 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2924 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2925 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2926 }
2927 }
2928 }
2929
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002930 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2931 // use that.
2932 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002933 if (IsArrow) {
2934 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2935 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2936 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002937 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002938 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002939 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2940 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002941 }
2942 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002943 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2944 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2945 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2946 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002947 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002948 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002949 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002950
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002951 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2952 // use that.
2953 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2954 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2955 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2956 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2957 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2958 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2959 }
2960 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002961
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002962 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002963
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002964 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002965 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002966 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2967 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2968 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2969 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2970 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2971 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2972 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2973 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2974 // Check the use of this method.
2975 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2976 return ExprError();
2977 }
2978 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2979 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2980 Selector SetterSel =
2981 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2982 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2983 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2984 if (!Setter) {
2985 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2986 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002987 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002988 }
2989 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2990 if (!Setter)
2991 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002992
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002993 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2994 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002995
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002996 if (Getter || Setter) {
2997 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002998
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002999 if (Getter)
3000 PType = Getter->getResultType();
3001 else
3002 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3003 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3004 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003005 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003006 PType,
3007 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3008 }
3009 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3010 << MemberName << BaseType);
3011 }
3012 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003013
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003014 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3015 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3016 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003017 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003018 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003019
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003020 if (IsArrow) {
3021 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003022 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003023 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3024 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003025 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3026 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3027 // struct MyRecord foo;
3028 // foo->bar
3029 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3030 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3031 // by now.
3032 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3033 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003034 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003035 IsArrow = false;
3036 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003037 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3038 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3039 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003040 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003041 } else {
3042 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3043 // type *foo;
3044 // foo.bar
3045 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3046 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3047 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3048 // the appropriate pointer type
3049 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3050 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3051 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3053 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003054 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003055 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3056 IsArrow = true;
3057 }
3058 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003059 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003060
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003061 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003062 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003063 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3064 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003065 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003066 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003067 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003068
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003069 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3070 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003071 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003072 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003073 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003074 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3075 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3076 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3077 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003078 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3079
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003080 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003081 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003082
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003083 if (!IV) {
3084 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3085 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3086 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003087 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003088 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003089 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003090 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3091 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003092 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3093 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003094 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003095 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003096 }
3097 }
3098
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003099 if (IV) {
3100 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3101 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3102 // error cases.
3103 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3104 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003105
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003106 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3107 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3108 return ExprError();
3109 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3110 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3111 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3112 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3113 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3114 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3115 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3116 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3117 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3118 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3119 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3120 // AST for a function decl.
3121 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003122 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003123 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3124 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3125 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3126 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3127 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3128 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003129
3130 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3131 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003132 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003133 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003134 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003135 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3136 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003137 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003138 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003139 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003140
3141 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3142 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003143 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003144 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003145 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003146 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003147 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003148 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003149 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003150 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003151 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3152 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003153 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003154 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003155
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003156 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003157 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003158 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3159 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3160 // Check the use of this declaration
3161 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3162 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003163
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003164 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3165 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3166 }
3167 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3168 // Check the use of this method.
3169 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3170 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003171
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003172 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor9a129192010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003173 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3174 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3175 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003176 }
3177 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003178
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003179 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003180 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003181 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003182
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003183 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3184 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003185 if (!IsArrow)
3186 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3187 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003188 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003189
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003190 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003191 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003192 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3193 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003194 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003195 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003196 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003197
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003198 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003199 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003200 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003201 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3202 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003203 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003204 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003205 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003206 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003207
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003208 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3209 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3210
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003211 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003212}
3213
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003214/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3215/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3216/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3217/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3218/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3219///
3220/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3221/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3222/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3223/// only be called
3224/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3225/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3226/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3227Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3228 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3229 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003230 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003231 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3232 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3233 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3234 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3235 return ExprError();
3236
3237 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3238
3239 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3240 DeclarationName Name;
3241 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3242 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3243 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3244 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3245
3246 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3247
3248 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3249 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3250 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3251
3252 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3253 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3254
3255 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3256 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003257 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3258 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003259 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3261 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3262 Name, NameLoc,
3263 TemplateArgs);
3264 } else {
3265 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3266 if (TemplateArgs) {
3267 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3268 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003269
Douglas Gregor9262f472010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003270 // Re-derive the naming class.
3271 if (SS.isSet()) {
3272 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3273 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3274 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3275 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3276 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3277 } else {
3278 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3279 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3280 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3281 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3282 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3283 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003284 } else {
3285 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003286 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003287
3288 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3289 Owned(Base);
3290 return ExprError();
3291 }
3292
3293 if (Result.get()) {
3294 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3295 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3296 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3297 // call now.
3298 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3299 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor0d5b0a12010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003300 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003301
3302 return move(Result);
3303 }
3304 }
3305
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003306 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003307 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3308 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003309 }
3310
3311 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003312}
3313
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003314Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3315 FunctionDecl *FD,
3316 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3317 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3318 Diag (CallLoc,
3319 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3320 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003321 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003322 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3323 } else {
3324 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3325 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3326
3327 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor8c702532010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003328 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3329 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003330
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003331 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3332 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregor01afeef2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003333 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003334
John McCall76d824f2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003335 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003336 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003337 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003338
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003339 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3340 InitializedEntity Entity
3341 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3342 InitializationKind Kind
3343 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3344 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3345 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3346
3347 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003348 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003349 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3350 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003351 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003352
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003353 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003354 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003355 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003356 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003357
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003358 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3359 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3360 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003361 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3362 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson714d0962009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003363 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3364 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003365 }
3366
3367 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003368 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003369}
3370
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003371/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3372/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3373/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3374/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3375/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3376/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003377bool
3378Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003379 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003380 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003381 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3382 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003383 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003384 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3385 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003386 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003387
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003388 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3389 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3390 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3391 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3392 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003393 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003394 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003395 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003396 }
3397
3398 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3399 // them.
3400 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3401 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3402 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3403 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003404 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003405 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003406 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3407 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3408 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003409 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003410 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003411 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003412 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003413 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003414 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003415 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3416 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3417 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3418 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3419 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003420 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003421 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003422 if (Invalid)
3423 return true;
3424 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3425 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3426 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003427
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003428 return false;
3429}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003430
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003431bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3432 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3433 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3434 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3435 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3436 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003437 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003438 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3439 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3440 bool Invalid = false;
3441 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3442 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3443 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3444 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003445 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003446 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003447 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003448
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003449 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003450 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3451 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003452
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003453 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3454 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003455 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003456 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003457 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003458
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003459 // Pass the argument
3460 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3461 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3462 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003463
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003464
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003465 InitializedEntity Entity =
3466 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3467 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3468 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3469 SourceLocation(),
3470 Owned(Arg));
3471 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3472 return true;
3473
3474 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003475 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003476 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003477
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003478 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003479 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003480 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3481 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003482
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003483 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003484 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003485 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003487
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003488 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003489 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003490 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003491 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003492 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003493 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003494 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495 }
3496 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003497 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003498}
3499
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003500/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003501/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3502/// locations.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003503Action::OwningExprResult
3504Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3505 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003507 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003508
3509 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3510 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003512 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003513 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner38dbdb22007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003514 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003515
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003516 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003517 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3518 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3519 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3520 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3521 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003522 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003523 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3524 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003525
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003526 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3527 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003528
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003529 NumArgs = 0;
3530 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003531
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003532 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3533 RParenLoc));
3534 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003535
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003536 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003537 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003538 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3539 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003540 bool Dependent = false;
3541 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3542 Dependent = true;
3543 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3544 Dependent = true;
3545
3546 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003547 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003548 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3549
3550 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3551 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3552 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3553 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3554
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003555 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3556
3557 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3558 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3559 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3560 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3561 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3562 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3563 // method template.
3564 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003565 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3566 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003567 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003568
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003569 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3570 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003571 }
3572
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003573 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003574 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003575 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003576 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003577 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3578 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003579 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003581 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003582 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003583 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3584 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003585 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3586 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003587 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003588
3589 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3590 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003591 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3592 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003593
3594 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3595 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003596 TheCall.get(), 0))
3597 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003598
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003599 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003600 RParenLoc))
3601 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003602
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003603 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3604 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003605 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003606 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3607 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003608 }
3609 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003610 }
3611
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003612 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003613 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003614 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003615
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003616 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003617 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3618 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003619 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003620 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003621 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003622
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003623 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3624 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3625 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3626
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003627 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3628}
3629
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003630/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3631/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003632/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3633/// block-pointer type.
3634///
3635/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3636Sema::OwningExprResult
3637Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3638 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3639 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3640 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3641 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3642
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003643 // Promote the function operand.
3644 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3645
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003646 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3647 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003648 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3649 Args, NumArgs,
3650 Context.BoolTy,
3651 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003652
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003653 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3654 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3655 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3656 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003657 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003658 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003659 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3660 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003661 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003662 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003663 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003664 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003665 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003666 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003667 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3668 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3669
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003670 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003671 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003672 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3673 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003674 return ExprError();
3675
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003676 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003677 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003678
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003679 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003680 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003681 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003682 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003683 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003684 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003685
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003686 if (FDecl) {
3687 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3688 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3689 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisddcd1322009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003690 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003691 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003692 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003693 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3694 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3695 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3696 }
3697 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003698 }
3699
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003700 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003701 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3702 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3703 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003704 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3705 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003706 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3707 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003708 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003709 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003710 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003711 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003712
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003713 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3714 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003715 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3716 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003717
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003718 // Check for sentinels
3719 if (NDecl)
3720 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003721
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003722 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003723 if (FDecl) {
3724 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3725 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003726
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003727 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003728 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3729 } else if (NDecl) {
3730 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3731 return ExprError();
3732 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003733
Anders Carlssonf8984012009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003734 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003735}
3736
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003737Action::OwningExprResult
3738Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3739 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003740 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003741 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003742 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003743
3744 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3745 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3746 if (!TInfo)
3747 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3748
3749 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3750}
3751
3752Action::OwningExprResult
3753Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3754 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3755 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003756 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003757
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003758 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003759 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003760 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3761 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003762 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3763 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003764 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003765 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003766 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003767 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003768
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003769 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003770 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003771 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003772 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003773 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003774 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3775 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3776 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3777 &literalType);
3778 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003779 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003780 InitExpr.release();
3781 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003782
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003783 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003784 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003785 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003786 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003787 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003788
3789 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003790
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003791 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003792 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003793}
3794
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003795Action::OwningExprResult
3796Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003797 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3798 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3799 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003800
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003801 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003802 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003803
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003804 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3805 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003806 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003807 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003808}
3809
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003810static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3811 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003812 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003813 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3814
3815 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3816 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003817 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3818 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahanian2b9fc832009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003819 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003820 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3821 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3822 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003823
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003824 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3825 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3826 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3827 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3828 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3829 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3830 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3831 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003832
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003833 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3834 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3835 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3836 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3837 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3838 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003839
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003840 // FIXME: Assert here.
3841 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3842 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3843}
3844
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003845/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003846bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003847 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003848 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003849 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003850 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003851 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3852 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003853
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003854 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003855
3856 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3857 // type needs to be scalar.
3858 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3859 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003860 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3861 return false;
3862 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003863
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003864 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003865 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003866 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3867 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003868 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003869 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3870 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003871 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 return false;
3873 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003874
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003875 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003876 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003877 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003878 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003879 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003880 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003881 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003882 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003883 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3884 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3885 break;
3886 }
3887 }
3888 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3889 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3890 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonec143772009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003891 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003892 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003893 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003894
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003895 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3896 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3897 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3898 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003899
3900 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003901 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003902 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3903 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003904 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003905 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003906
3907 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003908 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003909
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003910 if (castType->isVectorType())
3911 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3912 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3913 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3914
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003915 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3916 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003917
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003918 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003919 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3920 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3921 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3922 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3923 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3924 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3925 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3926 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3927 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3928 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003929 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003930
3931 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003932 return false;
3933}
3934
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003935bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3936 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003937 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003938
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003939 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003940 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003941 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003942 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003943 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003944 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003945 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003946 } else
3947 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003948 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003949 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003950
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003951 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003952 return false;
3953}
3954
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003956 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003957 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003958
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003959 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003960
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003961 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3962 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003963 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3964 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3965 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3966 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003967 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003968 return false;
3969 }
3970
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003971 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003972 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3973 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003974 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3975 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3976 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3977 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003978
3979 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3980 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3981 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003982
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003983 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003984 return false;
3985}
3986
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003987Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003988Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003989 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3990 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3991 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003992
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003993 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3994 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3995 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003996 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003997
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003998 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003999 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004000 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004001 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
4002 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004003
4004 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4005}
4006
4007Action::OwningExprResult
4008Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4009 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4010 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4011
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004012 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004013 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004014 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004015 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004016 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004017
Douglas Gregorb33eed02010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004018 Op.release();
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004019 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson5d270e82010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004020 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssonf10e4142009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004021 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004022}
4023
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004024/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4025/// of comma binary operators.
4026Action::OwningExprResult
4027Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4028 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4029 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4030 if (!E)
4031 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004032
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004033 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004034
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004035 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4036 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4037 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004038
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004039 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4040}
4041
4042Action::OwningExprResult
4043Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4044 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004045 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004046 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004047 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004048
4049 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004050 // then handle it as such.
4051 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4052 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4053 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4054 return ExprError();
4055 }
4056
4057 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4058 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4059 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4060
4061 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4062 // braces instead of the original commas.
4063 Op.release();
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004064 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4065 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004066 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4067 E->setType(Ty);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004068 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004069 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004070 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004071 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4072 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004073 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004074 }
4075}
4076
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004077Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004078 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004079 MultiExprArg Val,
4080 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004081 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4082 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004083 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4084 Expr *expr;
4085 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4086 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4087 else
4088 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004089 return Owned(expr);
4090}
4091
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004092/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4093/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004094/// C99 6.5.15
4095QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4096 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004097 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4098 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4099 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4100
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004101 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4102 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4103 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4104 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4105 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4106 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004107
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004108 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004109 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4110 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4111 << CondTy;
4112 return QualType();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004113 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004114
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004115 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004116 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4117 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004118
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004119 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4120 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004121 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4122 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4123 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004124 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004125
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004126 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4127 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004128 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4129 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004130 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004131 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004132 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004133 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004134 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004135 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004136
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004137 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004138 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004139 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4140 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4141 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4142 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4143 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4144 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4145 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004146 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4147 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004148 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004149 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004150 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4151 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004152 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004153 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004154 // promote the null to a pointer.
4155 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004156 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004157 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004158 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004159 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004160 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004161 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004162 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004163
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004164 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4165 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4166 QuestionLoc);
4167 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4168 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004169
4170
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004171 // Handle block pointer types.
4172 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4173 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4174 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4175 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004176 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4177 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004178 return destType;
4179 }
4180 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004181 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004182 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004183 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004184 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4185 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4186 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004187 return LHSTy;
4188 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004189 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004190 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4191 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004192
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004193 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4194 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004195 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004196 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004197 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4198 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4199 // to get a consistent AST.
4200 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004201 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4202 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004203 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004204 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004205 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004206 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4207 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004208 return LHSTy;
4209 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004210
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004211 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4212 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4213 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004214 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4215 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004216
4217 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4218 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4219 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004220 QualType destPointee
4221 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004222 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004223 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4224 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4225 // Promote to void*.
4226 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004227 return destType;
4228 }
4229 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004230 QualType destPointee
4231 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004232 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004233 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004234 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004235 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedmanb0bc5592009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004236 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004237 return destType;
4238 }
4239
4240 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4241 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4242 return LHSTy;
4243 }
4244 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4245 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4246 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4247 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4248 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4249 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4250 // to get a consistent AST.
4251 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004252 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4253 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004254 return incompatTy;
4255 }
4256 // The pointer types are compatible.
4257 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4258 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4259 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4260 // type.
4261 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4262 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004263 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4264 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 return LHSTy;
4266 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004267
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004268 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4269 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4270 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4271 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004272 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004273 return RHSTy;
4274 }
4275 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4276 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4277 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004278 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004279 return LHSTy;
4280 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004281
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004282 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004283 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4284 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004285 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004286}
4287
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004288/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4289/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4290QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4291 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4292 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4293 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004294
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004295 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4296 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4297 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4298 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4299 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4300 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4301 return LHSTy;
4302 }
4303 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4304 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4305 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4306 return RHSTy;
4307 }
4308 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4309 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4310 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4311 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4312 return LHSTy;
4313 }
4314 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4315 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4316 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4317 return RHSTy;
4318 }
4319 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4320 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4321 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4322 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4323 return LHSTy;
4324 }
4325 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4326 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4327 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4328 return RHSTy;
4329 }
4330 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4331 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004332
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004333 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4334 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4335 return LHSTy;
4336 }
4337 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4338 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4339 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004340
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004341 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4342 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4343 // type. This allows
4344 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4345 // where B is a subclass of A.
4346 //
4347 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4348 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4349 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4350 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004351
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004352 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4353 // It could return the composite type.
4354 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4355 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4356 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4357 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4358 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4359 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4360 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4361 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4362 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4363 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4364 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4365 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4366 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4367 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004368 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004369 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4370 ;
4371 else {
4372 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4373 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4374 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4375 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4376 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4378 return incompatTy;
4379 }
4380 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4381 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4382 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4383 return compositeType;
4384 }
4385 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4386 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4387 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4388 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4389 QualType destPointee
4390 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4391 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4392 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4394 // Promote to void*.
4395 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4396 return destType;
4397 }
4398 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4399 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4400 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4401 QualType destPointee
4402 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4403 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4404 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4405 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4406 // Promote to void*.
4407 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4408 return destType;
4409 }
4410 return QualType();
4411}
4412
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004413/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004414/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004415Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4416 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4417 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4418 ExprArg RHS) {
4419 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4420 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004421
4422 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4423 // was the condition.
4424 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4425 if (isLHSNull)
4426 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004427
4428 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattnerdaaa9f22007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004429 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004430 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004431 return ExprError();
4432
4433 Cond.release();
4434 LHS.release();
4435 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004436 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004437 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004438 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004439}
4440
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004441// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004442// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004443// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4444// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4445// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004446Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004447Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004448 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004449
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004450 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4451 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4452 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4453 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4454 return Compatible;
4455 }
4456
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004457 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004458 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4459 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004460
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004461 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004462 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4463 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004464
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004465 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004466
4467 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4468 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4469 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004470 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004471 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004472 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004473
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004474 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4475 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004476 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004477 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004478 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004479 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004480
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004481 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004482 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4483 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004484 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004485
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004486 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004487 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004488 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004489
4490 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004491 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4492 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004493 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004494 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004495 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004496 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4497 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4498 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4499 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4500 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4501 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004502 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004503 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004504 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004505 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004506
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004507 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004508 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004509 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004510 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004511
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004512 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4513 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4514 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4515 // warning can be disabled.
4516 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4517 return ConvTy;
4518 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4519 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004520
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004521 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4522 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4523 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4524 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4525 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4526 do {
4527 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4528 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004529
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004530 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4531 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4532 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004533
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004534 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004535 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004536 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004537
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004538 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004539 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004540 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004541 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004542}
4543
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004544/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4545/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4546/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4547// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004548Sema::AssignConvertType
4549Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004550 QualType rhsType) {
4551 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004552
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004553 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004554 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4555 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004556
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004557 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4558 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4559 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004560
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004561 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004562
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004563 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004564 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004565 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004566
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004567 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4568 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4569 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4570 }
4571 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004572 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004573 return ConvTy;
4574}
4575
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004576/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4577/// for assignment compatibility.
4578Sema::AssignConvertType
4579Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004580 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4581 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004582 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4583 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004584 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004585 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004586 }
4587 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4588 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004589 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4590 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004591 return IncompatiblePointer;
4592 return Compatible;
4593 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004594 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004595 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004596 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004597 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4598 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4599 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4600 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4601 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4602 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004603
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004604 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4605 return Compatible;
4606 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4607 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004608 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004609}
4610
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004611/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4612/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004613/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4614///
4615/// int a, *pint;
4616/// short *pshort;
4617/// struct foo *pfoo;
4618///
4619/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4620/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4621/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4622/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4623///
4624/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004625/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004626///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004627Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004628Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004629 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4630 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004631 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4632 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004633
4634 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004635 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004636
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004637 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4638 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4639 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4640 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4641 return Compatible;
4642 }
4643
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004644 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4645 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4646 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4647 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4648 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4649 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4650 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004651 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004652 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004653 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004654 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004655 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004656 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4657 // to the same ExtVector type.
4658 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4659 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4660 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4661 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4662 return Compatible;
4663 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004664
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004665 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004666 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004667 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004668 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004669 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4670 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004671 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004672 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004673 }
4674 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004675 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004676
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004677 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004678 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004679
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004680 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004681 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004682 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004683
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004684 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004685 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004686
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004687 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004688 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004689 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4690 return Compatible;
4691 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004692 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004693 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4694 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004695 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004696
4697 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004698 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004699 return Compatible;
4700 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004701 return Incompatible;
4702 }
4703
4704 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4705 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004706 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004707
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004708 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004709 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004710 return Compatible;
4711
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004712 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4713 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004715 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004716 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004717 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004718 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004719 return Incompatible;
4720 }
4721
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004722 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4723 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4724 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004725
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004726 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004727 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004728 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4729 return Compatible;
4730 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004731 }
4732 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004733 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004734 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004735 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004736 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4737 return Compatible;
4738 }
4739 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4740 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4741 return Compatible;
4742 return Incompatible;
4743 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004744 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004745 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004746 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4747 return Compatible;
4748
4749 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004750 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004751
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004752 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004753 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004754
4755 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004756 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004757 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004758 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004759 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004760 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4761 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4762 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4763 return Compatible;
4764
4765 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4766 return PointerToInt;
4767
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004768 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004769 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004770 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4771 return Compatible;
4772 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004773 }
4774 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004775 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004776 return Compatible;
4777 return Incompatible;
4778 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004779
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004780 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004781 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004782 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004783 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004784 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004785}
4786
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004787/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4788/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004789static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004790 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4791 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4792 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004793 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004794 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004795 SourceLocation());
4796 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4797 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4798
4799 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4800 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004801 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004802 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004803 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004804}
4805
4806Sema::AssignConvertType
4807Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4808 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4809
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004810 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004811 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4812 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004813 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004814 return Incompatible;
4815
4816 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4817 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4818 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4819 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004820 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4821 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004822 it != itend; ++it) {
4823 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4824 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4825 // 1) void pointer
4826 // 2) null pointer constant
4827 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004828 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004829 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004830 InitField = *it;
4831 break;
4832 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004833
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004834 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004835 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004836 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004837 InitField = *it;
4838 break;
4839 }
4840 }
4841
4842 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4843 == Compatible) {
4844 InitField = *it;
4845 break;
4846 }
4847 }
4848
4849 if (!InitField)
4850 return Incompatible;
4851
4852 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4853 return Compatible;
4854}
4855
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004856Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004857Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004858 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4859 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4860 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4861 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4862 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004863 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004864 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004865 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004866 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004867 }
4868
4869 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4870 // structures.
4871 }
4872
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004873 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4874 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004875 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4876 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004877 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004878 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004879 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004880 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004881 return Compatible;
4882 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004883
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004884 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004885 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004886 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004887 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004888 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004889 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004890 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004891 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004892
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004893 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4894 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004895
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004896 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4897 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004898 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4899 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4900 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4901 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004902 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004903 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4904 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004905 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004906}
4907
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004908QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004909 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004910 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004911 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004912 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00004913}
4914
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004915QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004916 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004917 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004918 QualType lhsType =
4919 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4920 QualType rhsType =
4921 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004922
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004923 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004924 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004925 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004926
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004927 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4928 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004929 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4930 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004931 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4932 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004933 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004934 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004935 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4936 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4937 return lhsType;
4938 }
4939
4940 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4941 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004942 }
4943 }
4944 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004945
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004946 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4947 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4948 bool swapped = false;
4949 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4950 swapped = true;
4951 std::swap(rex, lex);
4952 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4953 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004954
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004955 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004956 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004957 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4958 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4959 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004960 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004961 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4962 return lhsType;
4963 }
4964 }
4965 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4966 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4967 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004968 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004969 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4970 return lhsType;
4971 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004972 }
4973 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004974
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004975 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004976 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004977 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004978 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00004979 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004980}
4981
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004982QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4983 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004984 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004985 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004986
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004987 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004988
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004989 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4990 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4991 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004992
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004993 // Check for division by zero.
4994 if (isDiv &&
4995 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004996 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004997 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004998
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004999 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005000}
5001
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005002QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005003 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005004 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5005 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5006 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5007 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5008 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005009
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005010 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005011
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005012 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5013 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005014
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005015 // Check for remainder by zero.
5016 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005017 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5018 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005019
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005020 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005021}
5022
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005023QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005024 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005025 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5026 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5027 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5028 return compType;
5029 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005030
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005031 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005032
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005033 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005034 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5035 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5036 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005037 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005038 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005039
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005040 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5041 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005042 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005043 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5044
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005045 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005046
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005047 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005048 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005049
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005050 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5051 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005052 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5053 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005054 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005055 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005056 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005057
5058 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5059 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5060 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005061 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005062 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5063 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5064 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5065 return QualType();
5066 }
5067
5068 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5069 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5070 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005071 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005072 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005073 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005074 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005075 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5076 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005077 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5078 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005079 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005080 return QualType();
5081 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005082 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005083 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005084 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5085 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5086 return QualType();
5087 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005088
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005089 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005090 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5091 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5092 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5093 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5094 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005095 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005096 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5097 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005098 return PExp->getType();
5099 }
5100 }
5101
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005102 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005103}
5104
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005105// C99 6.5.6
5106QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005107 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5108 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5109 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5110 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5111 return compType;
5112 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005113
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005114 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005115
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005116 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005117
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005118 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005119 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5120 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005121 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005122 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005123 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005124
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005125 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005126 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005127 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005128
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005129 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005130
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005131 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5132 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5133 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5134 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5135 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5136 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5137 return QualType();
5138 }
5139
5140 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5141 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5142 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5143 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005145 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005146 return QualType();
5147 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005148
5149 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5150 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5151 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005153 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005154 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005155 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005156 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005157
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005158 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005159 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005160 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5161 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5162 return QualType();
5163 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005164
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005165 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005166 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5167 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5168 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5169 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5170 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5171 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005172 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005173 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5174
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005175 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005176 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005177 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005178
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005179 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005180 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005181 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005182
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005183 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5184 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5185 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5186 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5187 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5188 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5189 return QualType();
5190 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005191
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005192 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5193 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5194 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5195 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005196 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005197 return QualType();
5198 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005199
5200 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5201 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5202 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5203 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5204 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005205 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5206 << rex->getSourceRange()
5207 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005208 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005209
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005210 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5211 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5212 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5213 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5214 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5215 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5216 return QualType();
5217 }
5218 } else {
5219 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5220 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5221 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5222 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5223 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5224 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5225 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5226 return QualType();
5227 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005228 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005229
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005230 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5231 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5232 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5233 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5234 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005235 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005236 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005237
5238 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005239 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5240 }
5241 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005242
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005243 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005244}
5245
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005246// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005247QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005248 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005249 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5250 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005251 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005252
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005253 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5254 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5255 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5256
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005257 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5258 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005259 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5260 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5261 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5262 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5263 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005264 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005265 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005266 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005267
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005268 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005269
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005270 // Sanity-check shift operands
5271 llvm::APSInt Right;
5272 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005273 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5274 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005275 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005276 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5277 else {
5278 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5279 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5280 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5281 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5282 }
5283 }
5284
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005285 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005286 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005287}
5288
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005289// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005290QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005291 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5292 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5293
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005294 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005295 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005296 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005297
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005298 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff47fea352007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005299 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5300 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5301 else {
5302 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5303 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5304 }
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005305 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5306 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005307
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005308 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5309 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005310 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5311 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5312 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005313 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenekde9e9682009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005314 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005315 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5316 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5317 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5318 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenek9ffbe412009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005319 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5320 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005321 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005322
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005323 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5324 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5325 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5326 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005327
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005328 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5329 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005330 Expr *literalString = 0;
5331 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005332 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005333 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005334 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005335 literalString = lex;
5336 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005337 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5338 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005339 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005340 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005341 literalString = rex;
5342 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5343 }
5344
5345 if (literalString) {
5346 std::string resultComparison;
5347 switch (Opc) {
5348 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5349 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5350 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5351 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5352 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5353 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5354 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5355 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005356
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005357 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5358 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5359 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005360 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005361 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005362 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005363
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005364 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005365 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005366
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005367 if (isRelational) {
5368 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005369 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005370 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005371 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005372 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005373 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005374
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005375 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005376 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005377 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005378
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005379 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005380 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005381 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005382 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005383
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005384 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5385 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5386 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005387 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005388 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005389 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005390 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005391 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005392
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005393 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005394 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5395 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005396 if (!isRelational &&
5397 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5398 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5399 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5400 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5401 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5402 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5403 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5404 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5405 return ResultTy;
5406 }
5407 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005408 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5409 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5410 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5411 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5412 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5413 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005414 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005415 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005416 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005417 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005418 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005419 if (T.isNull()) {
5420 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5421 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5422 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005423 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005424 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005425 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005426 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005427 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005428 }
5429
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005430 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5431 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005432 return ResultTy;
5433 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005434 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5435 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5436 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5437 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5438 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5439 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5440 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5441 }
5442 } else if (!isRelational &&
5443 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5444 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5445 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5446 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5447 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5448 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5449 }
5450 } else {
5451 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005452 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005453 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005454 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005455 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005456 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005457 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005458 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005459
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005460 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005461 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005462 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005463 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005464 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5465 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005466 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005467 return ResultTy;
5468 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005469 if (LHSIsNull &&
5470 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5471 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson83133d92009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005472 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005473 return ResultTy;
5474 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005475
5476 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005477 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005478 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5479 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005480 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5481 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5482 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5483 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5484 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5485 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5486 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5487 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005488 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005489 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005490 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005491 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005492 if (T.isNull()) {
5493 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005494 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005495 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005496 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005497 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005498 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005499 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005500 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005501 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005502
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005503 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5504 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005505 return ResultTy;
5506 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005507
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005508 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005509 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5510 return ResultTy;
5511 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005512
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005513 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005514 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005515 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5516 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005517
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005518 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005519 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005520 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005521 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005522 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005523 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005524 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005525 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005526 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005527 if (!isRelational
5528 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5529 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005530 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005531 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005532 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005533 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005534 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5535 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5536 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005537 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005538 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005539 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005540 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005541
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005542 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005543 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005544 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5545 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005546 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005547 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005548 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005549 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005550
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005551 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5552 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005553 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005554 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005555 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005556 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005557 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005558 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005559 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005560 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005561 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5562 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005563 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005564 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005565 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005566 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005567 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005568 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5569 if (RHSIsNull) {
5570 if (isRelational)
5571 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5572 } else if (isRelational)
5573 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5574 else
5575 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005576
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005577 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005578 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005579 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005580 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005581 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005582 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005583 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005584 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005585 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5586 if (LHSIsNull) {
5587 if (isRelational)
5588 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5589 } else if (isRelational)
5590 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5591 else
5592 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005593
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005594 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005595 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005596 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005597 }
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005598 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005599 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005600 }
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005601 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005602 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5603 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005604 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005605 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005606 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005607 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5608 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005609 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005610 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005611 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005612 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005613}
5614
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005615/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005616/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005617/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5618/// types.
5619QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005620 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005621 bool isRelational) {
5622 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5623 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005624 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005625 if (vType.isNull())
5626 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005627
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005628 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5629 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005630
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005631 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5632 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5633 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5634 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5635 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5636 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5637 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005638 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005639 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005640
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005641 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5642 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5643 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005644 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005645 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005646
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005647 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5648 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5649 // elements for floating point vectors.
5650 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5651 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005652
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005653 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005654 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005655 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005656 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005657 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005658 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5659
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005660 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005661 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005662 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5663}
5664
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005665inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005666 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff94a5aca2007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005667 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005668 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005669
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005670 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005671
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005672 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005673 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005674 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005675}
5676
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005677inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005678 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005679 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5680 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5681 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005682
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005683 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5684 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005685
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005686 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005687 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005688
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005689 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5690 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
5691 // The operands are both implicitly converted to type bool (clause 4).
5692 StandardConversionSequence LHS;
5693 if (!IsStandardConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy,
5694 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, LHS))
5695 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005696
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005697 if (PerformImplicitConversion(lex, Context.BoolTy, LHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005698 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005699 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005700
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005701 StandardConversionSequence RHS;
5702 if (!IsStandardConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy,
5703 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, RHS))
5704 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005705
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005706 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rex, Context.BoolTy, RHS,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005707 AA_Passing, /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005708 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005709
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005710 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5711 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5712 // The result is a bool.
5713 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005714}
5715
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005716/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5717/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5718/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5719///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005720static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005721 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5722 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5723 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5724 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005725 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005726 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5727 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5728 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5729 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005730 }
5731 }
5732 return false;
5733}
5734
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005735/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5736/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5737static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005738 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005739 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005740 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005741 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5742 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005743 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5744 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005745
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746 unsigned Diag = 0;
5747 bool NeedType = false;
5748 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005749 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005750 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005751 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5752 NeedType = true;
5753 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005754 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005755 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5756 NeedType = true;
5757 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005758 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005759 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5760 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005761 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5762 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005764 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5765 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005766 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5767 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005768 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5769 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005770 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005771 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005772 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005773 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005774 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5775 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005776 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005777 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5778 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005779 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5780 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5781 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005782 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5783 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5784 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005785 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5786 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5787 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005788 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005789
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005790 SourceRange Assign;
5791 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5792 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005793 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005794 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005795 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005796 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005797 return true;
5798}
5799
5800
5801
5802// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005803QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5804 SourceLocation Loc,
5805 QualType CompoundType) {
5806 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5807 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005808 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005809
5810 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5811 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005812
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005813 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005814 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005815 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005816 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005817 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5818 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5819 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005820 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005821 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005822 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005823 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005824
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005825 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5826 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5827 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005828 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005829 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5830 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5831 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5832 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5833 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005834 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005835 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005836 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5837 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5838 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005839 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5840 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005841 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5842 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5843 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005844 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005845 }
5846 } else {
5847 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005848 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005849 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005850
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005851 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005852 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005853 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005854
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005855 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5856 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005857 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00005858 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5859 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005860 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005861 // operand.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005862 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005863}
5864
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005865// C99 6.5.17
5866QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattnerf6e1e302008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005867 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005868 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5869 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5870 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005871
5872 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5873 // incomplete in C++).
5874
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005875 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00005876}
5877
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005878/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5879/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005880QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005881 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005882 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5883 return Context.DependentTy;
5884
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005885 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5886 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00005887
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005888 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5889 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5890 if (!isInc) {
5891 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5892 return QualType();
5893 }
5894 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5895 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5896 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005897 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005898 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5899 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005900
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005901 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005902 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005903 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5904 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5905 << Op->getSourceRange();
5906 return QualType();
5907 }
5908
5909 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005910 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005911 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005912 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5913 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5914 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5915 return QualType();
5916 }
5917
5918 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005919 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005920 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005921 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005922 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005923 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005924 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005925 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005926 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005927 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5928 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5929 return QualType();
5930 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005931 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005932 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5933 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005934 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005935 } else {
5936 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005937 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005938 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00005939 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005940 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005941 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005942 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00005943 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005944 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5945 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5946 // operand.
5947 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5948 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005949}
5950
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005951/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005952/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005953/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5954/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5955/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5956/// - &(x) => x
5957/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5958/// - &s.xx => s
5959/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5960/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5961/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5962/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005963static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005964 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005965 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005966 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005967 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005968 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5969 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5970 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005971 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005972 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005973 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005974 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005975 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005976 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5977 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005978 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5979 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5980 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5981 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5982 }
5983 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005984 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005985 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5986 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005987
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005988 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005989 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5990 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5991 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5992 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5993 default:
5994 return 0;
5995 }
5996 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00005997 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005998 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005999 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006000 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6001 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006002 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006003 default:
6004 return 0;
6005 }
6006}
6007
6008/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006009/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006010/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006011/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006012/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006013/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006014/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006015QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006016 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6017 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6018
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006019 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6020 return Context.DependentTy;
6021
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006022 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6023 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6024 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6025 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6026 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6027 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6028 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6029 }
6030 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6031 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6032 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006033 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006034 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006035
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006036 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6037 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6038 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6039 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6040 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6041 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6042 // branch of the if, below.
6043 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6044 << dcl;
6045 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6046
6047 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6048 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6049 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6050 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006051 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6052 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6053 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6054 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6055 if (isSFINAEContext())
6056 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl9a8dd0d2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006057 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006058 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006059 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006060 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006061 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006062 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6063 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006064 return QualType();
6065 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006066 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006067 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6068 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6069 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006070 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006071 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006072 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006073 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006074 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006075 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006076 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6077 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6078 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6079 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6080 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006081 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6082 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006083 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6084 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006085 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6086 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006087 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006088 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006089 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6090 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006091 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006092 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6093 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006094 return QualType();
6095 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006096 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006097 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006098 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006099 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006100 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6101 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006102 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006103 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006104 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6105 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006106 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006107 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6108 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6109 return QualType();
6110 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006111
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006112 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6113 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006114 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006115 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006116 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes5773a1b2008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006117 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006118 // As above.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006119 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6120 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006121 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6122 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6123 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006124 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006125 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006126
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006127 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6128 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6129 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6130 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6131 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6132 }
6133
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006134 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006135 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006136}
6137
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006138QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006139 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6140 return Context.DependentTy;
6141
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006142 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6143 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006144
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006145 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6146 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6147 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6148 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006149 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006150 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006151
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006152 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanianf15d4b62009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006153 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006154
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006155 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006156 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006157 return QualType();
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006158}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006159
6160static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6161 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6162 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6163 switch (Kind) {
6164 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006165 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6166 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006167 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6168 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6169 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6170 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6171 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6172 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6173 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6174 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6175 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6176 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6177 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6178 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6179 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6180 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6181 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6182 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6183 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6184 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6185 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6186 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6187 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6188 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6189 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6190 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6191 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6192 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6193 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6194 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6195 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6196 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6197 }
6198 return Opc;
6199}
6200
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006201static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6202 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6203 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6204 switch (Kind) {
6205 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6206 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6207 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6208 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6209 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6210 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6211 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6212 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6213 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006214 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6215 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
Chris Lattnerd0f76512007-06-08 22:16:53 +00006216 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006217 }
6218 return Opc;
6219}
6220
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006221/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6222/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6223/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006224Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6225 unsigned Op,
6226 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006227 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006228 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006229 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6230 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6231 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006232
6233 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006234 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6235 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6236 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006237 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6238 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6239 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6240 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6241 break;
6242 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006243 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006244 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6245 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006246 break;
6247 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6248 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6249 break;
6250 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6251 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6252 break;
6253 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6254 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6255 break;
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006256 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006257 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6258 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6259 break;
6260 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6261 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6262 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6263 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006264 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006265 break;
6266 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6267 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006268 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006269 break;
6270 case BinaryOperator::And:
6271 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6272 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6273 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6274 break;
6275 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6276 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6277 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6278 break;
6279 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6280 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006281 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6282 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006283 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6284 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6285 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006286 break;
6287 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006288 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6289 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6290 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6291 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006292 break;
6293 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006294 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6295 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6296 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006297 break;
6298 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006299 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6300 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6301 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006302 break;
6303 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6304 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006305 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6306 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6307 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6308 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006309 break;
6310 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6311 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6312 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006313 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6314 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6315 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6316 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006317 break;
6318 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6319 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6320 break;
6321 }
6322 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006323 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006324 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006325 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6326 else
6327 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006328 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6329 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006330}
6331
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006332/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6333/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006334static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6335 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006336 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6337 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6338 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006339 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006340 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6341
6342 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6343 return;
6344
6345 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6346 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6347 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006348 return;
6349 }
6350
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006351 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6352 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006353 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006354
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006355 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006356 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006357
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006358 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6359 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6360 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6361 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006362 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006363 return;
6364 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006365
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006366 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006367 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6368 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006369}
6370
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006371/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6372/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6373/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6374/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006375static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6376 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006377 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6378 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6379 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6380 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006381 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006382 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006383 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6384
6385 // Subs are not binary operators.
6386 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6387 return;
6388
6389 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6390 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006391 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6392 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006393 return;
6394
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006395 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006396 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006397 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006398 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6399 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006400 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006401 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006402 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6403 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6404 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6405 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006406 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006407 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006408 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006409 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6410 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006411 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006412 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006413 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6414 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6415 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6416 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006417}
6418
6419/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6420/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6421/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6422static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6423 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006424 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006425 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6426}
6427
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006428// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006429Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6430 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6431 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006432 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006433 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006434
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006435 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6436 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006437
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006438 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6439 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6440
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006441 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6442}
6443
6444Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6445 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6446 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006447 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006448 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006449 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6450 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6451 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6452 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6453 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006454 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006455 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006456 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6457 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6458 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006459
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006460 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6461 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006462 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006463 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006464
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006465 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006466 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006467}
6468
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006469Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006470 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006471 ExprArg InputArg) {
6472 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006473
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006474 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006475 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006476 QualType resultType;
6477 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006478 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6479 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6480 break;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006481
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006482 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6483 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006484 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6485 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006486 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedman6aea5752009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006487 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006488 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6489 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6490 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006491 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006492 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006493 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006494 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006495 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006496 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006497 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006498 break;
6499 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6500 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006501 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6502 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006503 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6504 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006505 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6506 break;
6507 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6508 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6509 break;
6510 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6511 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6512 resultType->isPointerType())
6513 break;
6514
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006515 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6516 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006517 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006518 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6519 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006520 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6521 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006522 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6523 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6524 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006525 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006526 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006527 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006528 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6529 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006530 break;
6531 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006532 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006533 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006534 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006535 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6536 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006537 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006538 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6539 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006540 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006541 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6542 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006543 break;
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006544 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006545 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006546 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006547 break;
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006548 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006549 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006550 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006551 }
6552 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006553 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006554
6555 InputArg.release();
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006556 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006557}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006558
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006559Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6560 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6561 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006562 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006563 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6564 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006565 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6566 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6567 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6568 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006569 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006570 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006571 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6572 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6573 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006574
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006575 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6576 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006577
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006578 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6579}
6580
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006581// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6582Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6583 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6584 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6585}
6586
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006587/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006588Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6589 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6590 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006591 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattner3318e862009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006592 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006593
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006594 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6595 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006596 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006597 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006598
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006599 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006600 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6601 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006602}
6603
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006604Sema::OwningExprResult
6605Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6606 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6607 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006608 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6609 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6610
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006611 bool isFileScope
6612 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006613 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006614 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006615
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006616 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6617 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6618 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006619
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006620 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6621 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6622 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006623
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006624 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6625 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6626 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6627 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6628 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006629
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006630 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006631 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006632 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006633
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006634 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6635 // expressions are not lvalues.
6636
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006637 substmt.release();
6638 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006639}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006640
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006641Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6642 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006643 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6644 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006645 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6646 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006647 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006648 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006649
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006650 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6651 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6652 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006653 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006654 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6655 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6656
6657 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6658 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6659 if (!Dependent
6660 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6661 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6662 << TypeRange))
6663 return ExprError();
6664
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006665 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6666 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006667 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6668 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006669 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006670 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6671 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006672
6673 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6674 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6675 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6676 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6677 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6678 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6679 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6680 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6681 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6682 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6683 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6684 if(!AT)
6685 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6686 << CurrentType);
6687 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6688 } else
6689 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6690
6691 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6692 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6693 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6694 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6695 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6696 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6697 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6698 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6699
6700 // Record this array index.
6701 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6702 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6703 continue;
6704 }
6705
6706 // Offset of a field.
6707 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6708 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6709 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6710 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6711 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6712 continue;
6713 }
6714
6715 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6716 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6717 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6718 return ExprError();
6719
6720 // Look for the designated field.
6721 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6722 if (!RC)
6723 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6724 << CurrentType);
6725 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6726
6727 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6728 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6729 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6730 // (clause 9).
6731 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6732 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6733 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6734 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6735 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6736 << CurrentType))
6737 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6738 }
6739
6740 // Look for the field.
6741 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6742 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6743 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6744 if (!MemberDecl)
6745 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6746 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6747 OC.LocEnd));
6748
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006749 // C99 7.17p3:
6750 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6751 //
6752 // We diagnose this as an error.
6753 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6754 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6755 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6756 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6757 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6758 return ExprError();
6759 }
6760
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006761 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6762 // the base class indirections.
6763 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6764 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6765 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6766 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6767 Paths)) {
6768 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6769 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6770 B != BEnd; ++B)
6771 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6772 }
6773
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006774 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006775 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006776 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6777 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6778 unsigned n = Path.size();
6779 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6780 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6781 } else {
6782 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6783 }
6784 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6785 }
6786
6787 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6788 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6789 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6790}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006791
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006792Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6793 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6794 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6795 TypeTy *argty,
6796 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6797 unsigned NumComponents,
6798 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6799
6800 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6801 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6802 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6803 return ExprError();
6804
6805 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6806 if (!ArgTInfo)
6807 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6808
6809 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6810 RPLoc);
6811 }
6812
6813 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6814 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6815
6816 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6817
6818 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6819 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6820 // a struct/union/class.
6821 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6822 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6823
6824 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6825 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6826
6827 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6828 // the offsetof designators.
6829 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6830 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6831 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6832 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6833
6834 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6835 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6836 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6837 // a system header!
6838 if (NumComponents != 1)
6839 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6840 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6841
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006842 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedman8469bc72009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006843 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006844
John McCall9eff4e62009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006845 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6846 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6847 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006848
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006849 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6850 // leaks like a sieve.
6851 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6852 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6853 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6854 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6855 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6856 if (!AT) {
6857 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006858 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006859 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006860 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006861
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006862 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006863
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006864 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6865 // expression.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006866 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006867
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006868 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6869 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006870 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006871 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006872 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006873 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006874 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6875
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006876 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6877 OC.LocEnd);
6878 continue;
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006879 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006880
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006881 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006882 if (!RC) {
6883 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006884 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006885 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006886 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006887
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006888 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6889 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006890 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006891 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6892 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6893 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006894 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6895 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006896 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson2bbb86b2009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006897 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006898
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006899 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6900 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006901
John McCall67c00872009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006902 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006903 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006904 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregore40876a2009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006905 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006906 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6907
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006908 // C99 7.17p3:
6909 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6910 //
6911 // We diagnose this as an error.
6912 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6913 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6914 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6915 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6916 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6917 return ExprError();
6918 }
6919
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006920 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6921 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006922 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlsson3cbc8592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006923 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006924 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006925 } else {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006926 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6927 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006928 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6929 // doesn't matter here.
6930 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006931 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedman64fc3c62009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006932 }
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006933 }
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006934 }
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006935
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006936 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6937 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006938}
6939
6940
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006941Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6942 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6943 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006944 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6945 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6946 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006947
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006948 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006949
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006950 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6951 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6952 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6953 return ExprError();
6954 }
6955
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006956 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6957 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006958}
6959
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006960Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6961 ExprArg cond,
6962 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6963 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6964 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6965 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6966 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006967
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006968 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6969
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006970 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006971 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006972 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006973 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006974 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006975 } else {
6976 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6977 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6978 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6979 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006980 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6981 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6982 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006983
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006984 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6985 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006986 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6987 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006988 }
6989
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006990 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6991 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006992 resType, RPLoc,
6993 resType->isDependentType(),
6994 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006995}
6996
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006997//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6998// Clang Extensions.
6999//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7000
7001/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007002void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007003 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7004 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7005 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7006 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007007}
7008
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007009void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007010 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007011 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007012
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007013 if (ParamInfo.getNumTypeObjects() == 0
7014 || ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind != DeclaratorChunk::Function) {
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007015 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007016 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
7017
Mike Stumpd456c482009-04-28 01:10:27 +00007018 if (T->isArrayType()) {
7019 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7020 diag::err_block_returns_array);
7021 return;
7022 }
7023
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007024 // The parameter list is optional, if there was none, assume ().
7025 if (!T->isFunctionType())
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00007026 T = Context.getFunctionType(T, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
7027 FunctionType::ExtInfo());
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007028
7029 CurBlock->hasPrototype = true;
7030 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007031 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007032 if (CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007033 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007034 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007035 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7036 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007037 QualType RetTy = T.getTypePtr()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007038
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007039 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007040 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007041 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7042 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7043 return;
7044 }
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007045
7046 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007047 return;
7048 }
7049
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007050 // Analyze arguments to block.
7051 assert(ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
7052 "Not a function declarator!");
7053 DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = ParamInfo.getTypeObject(0).Fun;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007054
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007055 CurBlock->hasPrototype = FTI.hasPrototype;
7056 CurBlock->isVariadic = true;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007057
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007058 // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs function that takes
7059 // no arguments, not a function that takes a single void argument.
7060 if (FTI.hasPrototype &&
7061 FTI.NumArgs == 1 && !FTI.isVariadic && FTI.ArgInfo[0].Ident == 0 &&
Chris Lattner83f095c2009-03-28 19:18:32 +00007062 (!FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType().getCVRQualifiers()&&
7063 FTI.ArgInfo[0].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>()->getType()->isVoidType())) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007064 // empty arg list, don't push any params.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007065 CurBlock->isVariadic = false;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007066 } else if (FTI.hasPrototype) {
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007067 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumArgs; i != e; ++i) {
7068 ParmVarDecl *Param = FTI.ArgInfo[i].Param.getAs<ParmVarDecl>();
7069 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7070 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7071 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7072 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7073 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
7074 CurBlock->Params.push_back(Param);
7075 }
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007076 CurBlock->isVariadic = FTI.isVariadic;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007077 }
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00007078 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(CurBlock->Params.data(),
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007079 CurBlock->Params.size());
Fariborz Jahanian960910a2009-05-19 17:08:59 +00007080 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(CurBlock->isVariadic);
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007081 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007082
7083 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7084 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7085
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007086 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007087 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7088 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7089
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007090 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007091 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7092 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7093 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7094
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007095 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007096 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007097 }
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007098
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007099 // Check for a valid sentinel attribute on this block.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007100 if (!CurBlock->isVariadic &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00007101 CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007102 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
Fariborz Jahanian6802ed92009-05-15 21:18:04 +00007103 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
Fariborz Jahanian6607b212009-05-14 20:53:39 +00007104 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7105 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007106
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007107 // Analyze the return type.
7108 QualType T = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007109 QualType RetTy = T->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007110
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007111 // Do not allow returning a objc interface by-value.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007112 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner6de05082009-04-11 19:27:54 +00007113 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7114 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7115 } else if (!RetTy->isDependentType())
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007116 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007117}
7118
7119/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7120/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7121void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007122 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007123 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007124 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007125 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007126}
7127
7128/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7129/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007130Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7131 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007132 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7133 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7134 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007135
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007136 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007137
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007138 PopDeclContext();
7139
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007140 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007141 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7142 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007143
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007144 llvm::SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7145 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Params.size(); i != e; ++i)
7146 ArgTypes.push_back(BSI->Params[i]->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007147
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007148 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007149 QualType BlockTy;
7150 if (!BSI->hasPrototype)
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007151 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007152 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007153 else
Jay Foad7d0479f2009-05-21 09:52:38 +00007154 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, ArgTypes.data(), ArgTypes.size(),
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007155 BSI->isVariadic, 0, false, false, 0, 0,
Rafael Espindola49b85ab2010-03-30 22:15:11 +00007156 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007157
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007158 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007159 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->Params.begin(), BSI->Params.end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007160 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007161
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007162 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007163 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007164 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007165
Anders Carlssonb781bcd2009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007166 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007167
7168 bool Good = true;
7169 // Check goto/label use.
7170 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7171 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7172 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7173
7174 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7175 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7176 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7177 continue;
7178
7179 // Emit error.
7180 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7181 Good = false;
7182 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007183 if (!Good) {
7184 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007185 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007186 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007187
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007188 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007189 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7190 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7191 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007192
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007193 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7194 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007195 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007196 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007197}
7198
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007199Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7200 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7201 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc7148c92009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007202 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007203 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7204 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007205
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007206 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007207
7208 // Get the va_list type
7209 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007210 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7211 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7212 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7213 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007214 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007215 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7216 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7217 } else {
7218 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7219 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007220 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007221 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007222 return ExprError();
7223 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007224
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007225 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7226 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007227 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7228 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007229 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007230 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007231
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007232 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007233 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007234
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007235 expr.release();
7236 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7237 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007238}
7239
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007240Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007241 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7242 // pointers on the target.
7243 QualType Ty;
7244 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7245 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7246 else
7247 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7248
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007249 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007250}
7251
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007252static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007253 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007254 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7255 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007256
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007257 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7258 if (!PT)
7259 return;
7260
7261 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7262 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7263 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7264 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7265 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7266 return;
7267 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007268
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007269 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7270 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7271 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7272 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007273
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007274 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007275}
7276
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007277bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7278 SourceLocation Loc,
7279 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007280 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7281 bool *Complained) {
7282 if (Complained)
7283 *Complained = false;
7284
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007285 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7286 bool isInvalid = false;
7287 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007288 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007289
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007290 switch (ConvTy) {
7291 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7292 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007293 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007294 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7295 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007296 case IntToPointer:
7297 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7298 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007299 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007300 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007301 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7302 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007303 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7304 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7305 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007306 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7307 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7308 break;
7309 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007310 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7311 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7312 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7313 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7314 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7315 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7316 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7317 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7318 // C++ semantics.
7319 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7320 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7321 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007322 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7323 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007324 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007325 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007326 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007327 case IntToBlockPointer:
7328 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7329 break;
7330 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007331 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007332 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007333 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007334 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007335 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7336 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7337 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007338 case IncompatibleVectors:
7339 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7340 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007341 case Incompatible:
7342 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7343 isInvalid = true;
7344 break;
7345 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007346
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007347 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7348 switch (Action) {
7349 case AA_Assigning:
7350 case AA_Initializing:
7351 // The destination type comes first.
7352 FirstType = DstType;
7353 SecondType = SrcType;
7354 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007355
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007356 case AA_Returning:
7357 case AA_Passing:
7358 case AA_Converting:
7359 case AA_Sending:
7360 case AA_Casting:
7361 // The source type comes first.
7362 FirstType = SrcType;
7363 SecondType = DstType;
7364 break;
7365 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007366
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007367 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007368 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007369 if (Complained)
7370 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007371 return isInvalid;
7372}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007373
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007374bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007375 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7376 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7377 if (Result)
7378 *Result = ICEResult;
7379 return false;
7380 }
7381
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007382 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7383
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007384 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007385 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7386 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7387
7388 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7389 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7390 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7391 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7392 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7393 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7394 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007395
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007396 return true;
7397 }
7398
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007399 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7400 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007401
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007402 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7403 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7404 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007405
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007406 if (Result)
7407 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7408 return false;
7409}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007410
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007411void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007412Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007413 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7414 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007415}
7416
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007417void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007418Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7419 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7420 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7421 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007422
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007423 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7424 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7425 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7426 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7427 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007428 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007429 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7430 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7431 I != IEnd; ++I)
7432 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7433 }
7434
7435 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7436 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7437 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7438 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7439 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7440 I != IEnd; ++I)
7441 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7442 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007443 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007444
7445 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7446 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7447 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7448 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007449 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007450 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7451 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7452 ExprTemporaries.end());
7453
7454 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7455 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007456}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007457
7458/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7459///
7460/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7461/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7462/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7463/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7464///
7465/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7466///
7467/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7468void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7469 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007470
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007471 if (D->isUsed())
7472 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007473
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007474 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7475 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7476 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7477 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007478 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007479 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007480 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007481 return;
7482 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007483
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007484 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7485 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007486
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007487 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7488 // an instantiation.
7489 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7490 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007491
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007492 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007493 case Unevaluated:
7494 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7495 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007496
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007497 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7498 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7499 // "used"; handle this below.
7500 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007501
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007502 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7503 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7504 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7505 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007506 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007507 return;
7508 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007509
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007510 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007511 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007512 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007513 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7514 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7515 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007516 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007517 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007518 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7519 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7520 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007521
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007522 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007523 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7524 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7525 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007526 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7527 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007528 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7529 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7530 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7531 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007532 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007533 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7534 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007535 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007536 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007537 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007538 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007539 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007540 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7541 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7542 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7543 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7544 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007545 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007546 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007547 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007548 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007549 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7550 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7551 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007552 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007553 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007554 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7555 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007556
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007557 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7558 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7559 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7560 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7561 Loc));
7562 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007563 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007564 Loc));
7565 }
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007566 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007567
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007568 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007569 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007570
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007571 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007572 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007573
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007574 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007575 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007576 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007577 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7578 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7579 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7580 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7581 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7582 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7583 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7584 }
7585 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007586
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007587 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007588
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007589 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007590 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007591 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007592}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007593
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007594namespace {
7595 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7596 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7597 // of when we're entering
7598 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7599 Sema &S;
7600 SourceLocation Loc;
7601
7602 public:
7603 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7604
7605 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7606
7607 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7608 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7609 };
7610}
7611
7612bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7613 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7614 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7615 }
7616
7617 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7618}
7619
7620bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7621 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7622 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7623 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7624 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7625 Args.flat_size());
7626 }
7627
7628 return false;
7629}
7630
7631void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7632 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7633 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7634}
7635
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007636/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7637/// of the program being compiled.
7638///
7639/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007640/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007641/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7642/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7643/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7644/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007645/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007646/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007647///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007648/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7649/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7650/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7651/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007652bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007653 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7654 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7655 case Unevaluated:
7656 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7657 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007658
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007659 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7660 Diag(Loc, PD);
7661 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007662
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007663 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7664 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7665 break;
7666 }
7667
7668 return false;
7669}
7670
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007671bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7672 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7673 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7674 return false;
7675
7676 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7677 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7678 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7679 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007681 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007682 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007683 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7684 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007685 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007686 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7687 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7688 return true;
7689
7690 return false;
7691}
7692
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007693// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7694// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7695void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7696 SourceLocation Loc;
7697
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007698 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7699
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007700 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7701 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7702 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7703 return;
7704
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007705 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7706 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7707 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7708 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7709
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007710 // self = [<foo> init...]
7711 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7712 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7713 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7714
7715 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7716 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7717 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7718 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7719 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007720
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007721 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7722 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7723 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7724 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7725 return;
7726
7727 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7728 } else {
7729 // Not an assignment.
7730 return;
7731 }
7732
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007733 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007734 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007735
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007736 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007737 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007738 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007739 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7740 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7741 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007742}
7743
7744bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7745 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7746
7747 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007748 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007749
7750 QualType T = E->getType();
7751
7752 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7753 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7754 return true;
7755 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7756 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7757 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7758 return true;
7759 }
7760 }
7761
7762 return false;
7763}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007764
7765Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7766 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007767 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7768 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007769 return ExprError();
7770
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007771 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7772 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7773 return ExprError();
7774 }
7775
7776 return Owned(Sub);
7777}